blob: 50f023abc8e0248a53fac35b4bfa1ee4aba6de0d [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000041
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +000059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
60 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
61 // emit them now.
62 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
63 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
64 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
65 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
66 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
67 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
68
69 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
70 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
71 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
72 // diagnostics again.
73 Suppressed.clear();
74 }
75 }
76
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000077 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000078 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
79 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000081 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc74073c2010-10-06 23:12:32 +000082 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
83 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
84 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
85 else
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000087 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000088 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
89 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000090
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000091 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000092 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000093 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
94 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
95 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
96 return true;
97 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000100 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000101}
102
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000103/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000104/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000105/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
106///
107void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000109 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000110 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000111 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000112
113 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
114 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000115 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
116 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000117
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000118 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
119 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000120 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000121 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
122 int isMethod = 0;
123 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
124 // skip over named parameters.
125 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
126 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
127 if (nullPos)
128 --nullPos;
129 else
130 ++i;
131 }
132 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
133 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000134 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000135 // skip over named parameters.
136 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
137 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
138 if (nullPos)
139 --nullPos;
140 else
141 ++i;
142 }
143 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000144 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000145 // block or function pointer call.
146 QualType Ty = V->getType();
147 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000148 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000149 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
150 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000151 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
152 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
153 unsigned k;
154 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
155 if (nullPos)
156 --nullPos;
157 else
158 ++i;
159 }
160 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
161 }
162 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
163 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000164 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000165 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000166 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000167 return;
168
169 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000170 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000171 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000172 return;
173 }
174 int sentinel = i;
175 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
176 --sentinelPos;
177 ++i;
178 }
179 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
180 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000181 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000182 return;
183 }
184 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
185 ++i;
186 ++sentinel;
187 }
188 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000189 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
190 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
191 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000192 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000193 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
194 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
195 return;
196
197 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
198 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
199
200 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
201 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000202}
203
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000204SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
205 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
206 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
207}
208
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000209//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
210// Standard Promotions and Conversions
211//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
212
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
214void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
215 QualType Ty = E->getType();
216 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
217
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000218 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000219 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000220 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000221 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
222 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
223 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
224 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
225 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
226 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
227 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000228 //
229 // C++ 4.2p1:
230 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
231 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
232 //
233 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
234 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000235 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000236 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000237 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000238}
239
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000240void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
241 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000242
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000243 QualType Ty = E->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
245 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
246 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
247 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
248 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
249 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
250 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
251 // rvalue is T
252 //
253 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000254 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
255 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000256 // type of the lvalue.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000257 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000258 }
259}
260
261
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000262/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000263/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000264/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
265/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
266/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
267Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
268 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
269 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000270
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000271 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
272 //
273 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
274 // unsigned int may be used:
275 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
276 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
277 // and unsigned int.
278 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
279 //
280 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
281 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
282 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
283 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000284 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
285 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000286 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000287 return Expr;
288 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000289 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000290 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000291 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000292 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000293 }
294
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000295 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000296 return Expr;
297}
298
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000299/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000300/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000301/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
302void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
303 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
304 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000305
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000306 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000307 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
308 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000309 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000310
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000311 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
312}
313
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
315/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
316/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
317/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000318bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
319 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000320 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000322 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
323 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
324 // etc.
325 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
326 return false;
327
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000328 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000329 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
330 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
331 << Expr->getType() << CT))
332 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000333
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000334 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000335 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000336 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
337 << Expr->getType() << CT))
338 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000339
340 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000341}
342
343
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000344/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
345/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000346/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000347/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
348/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
349/// GCC.
350QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
351 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000352 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000353 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000354
355 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000356
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000357 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000358 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000359 QualType lhs =
360 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000361 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000362 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000363
364 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
365 if (lhs == rhs)
366 return lhs;
367
368 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
369 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
370 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
371 return lhs;
372
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000373 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000374 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000375 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
376 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000377 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000378 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
379 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
380
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000381 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000382 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000383 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
384 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000385 return destType;
386}
387
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000388//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
389// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
390//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
391
392
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000393/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000394/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
395/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
396/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
397/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000398///
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000399ExprResult
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000400Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
402
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000403 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000404 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000405 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000406
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000407 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000408 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
409 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000410
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000411 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000412 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000413 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000414
415 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000416 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000417 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000418
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000419 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
420 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
421 // strings.
422 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000423 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000424 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000425
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000426 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000427 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
428 Literal.GetStringLength(),
429 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
430 &StringTokLocs[0],
431 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000432}
433
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000434/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
435/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
436/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
437/// for values inside the block or for globals).
438///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000439/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000440/// up-to-date.
441///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000443 ValueDecl *VD) {
444 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
445 // we wanted to.
446 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
447 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000448
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000449 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
450 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
451 return false;
452
453 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
454 // snapshot it.
455 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
456 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000457 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
458 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000460 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
461 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
462
463 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
464 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
465 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
466 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000467 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
468 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000469
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000470 if (!NextBlock)
471 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000472
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000473 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
474 // having a reference outside it.
475 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
476 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000477
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000478 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
479 // a snapshot as well.
480 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
481 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000482
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000483 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000484}
485
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000486
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000487ExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000488Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000489 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000490 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
491 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
492}
493
494/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000495ExprResult
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000496Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
497 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
498 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000499 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000500 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000501 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000502 << D->getDeclName();
503 return ExprError();
504 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000505
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000506 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000507 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
508 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
509 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000510 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000511 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000512 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
513 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000514 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
515 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000516 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000517 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000518 << D->getIdentifier();
519 return ExprError();
520 }
521 }
522 }
523 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000524
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000525 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000526
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000527 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
528 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
529 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000530 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000531}
532
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
534/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
535/// actual member.
536///
537/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
538/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
539/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
540/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
541/// we found.
542///
543/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
544/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
545/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
546VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
547 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000548 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
549 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
550 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
551
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000552 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000553 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
554 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
555 do {
556 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000557 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000558 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000559 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000560 else {
561 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
562 break;
563 }
564 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000565 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000566 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000567
568 return BaseObject;
569}
570
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000571ExprResult
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000572Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
573 FieldDecl *Field,
574 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
575 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
576 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000577 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000578 AnonFields);
579
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
581 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
582 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
583 // found via name lookup.
584 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000585 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000586 if (BaseObject) {
587 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
588 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000589 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000590 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patele25b5f82010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000591 Loc);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000592 BaseQuals
593 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000594 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
595 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
596 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
597 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
598 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000599 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000600 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
601 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
602 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000603 BaseQuals
604 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000605 } else {
606 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
607 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
608 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000609 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
610 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000611 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000612 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 = Context.getTagDeclType(
614 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
615 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000616 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000617 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
618 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
619 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000620 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000621 MD->getThisType(Context),
622 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000623 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
624 }
625 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000626 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
627 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000628 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000629 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000630 }
631
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000632 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000633 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
634 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 }
636
637 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
638 // anonymous struct/union.
639 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000640 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000641 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
642 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
643 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
644 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000645 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
646 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
647
648 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
649 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
650 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
651 ResultQuals.removeConst();
652
653 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
654 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
655
656 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
657 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
658
659 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
660 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
661 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
662
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000663 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000664 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000665 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000666 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
667 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000668 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000669 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000670 }
671
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000672 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000673}
674
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000675/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000676/// possibly a list of template arguments.
677///
678/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
679/// DecomposeTemplateName.
680///
681/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
682/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
683/// some way.
684static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
685 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
686 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000687 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000688 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
689 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
690 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
691 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
692
693 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
694 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
695 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
696 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
697 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
698
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000699 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000700 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
701 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000702 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
703 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000704 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000705 TemplateArgs = 0;
706 }
707}
708
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000709/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
710/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
711/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000712static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000713 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
714 return false;
715
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000716 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
717 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
718 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
719 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
720 if (!BaseRT) return false;
721
722 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000723 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000724 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
725 return false;
726 }
727
728 return true;
729}
730
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000731/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
732/// the prospective base classes.
733static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
734 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
735 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000736 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000737 return false;
738
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000739 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000740 if (!RD) return false;
741 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
742
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000743 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
744 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
745 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
746 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
747 if (!BaseRT) return false;
748
749 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000750 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
751 return false;
752 }
753
754 return true;
755}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000756
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000757enum IMAKind {
758 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
759 IMA_Static,
760
761 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
762 IMA_Mixed,
763
764 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
765 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
766 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
767
768 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
769 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
770 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
771
772 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
773 IMA_Instance,
774
775 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
776 IMA_Unresolved,
777
778 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
779 /// context is not an instance method.
780 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
781
782 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
783 /// non-class context.
784 IMA_AnonymousMember,
785
786 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
787 /// context is not an instance method.
788 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
789
790 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
791 /// class.
792 IMA_Error_Unrelated
793};
794
795/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
796/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
797/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
798/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
799/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
800/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
801static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
802 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000803 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000804
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000805 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000806 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000807 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
808 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000809
810 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
811 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
812
813 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
814 bool hasNonInstance = false;
815 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
816 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000817 NamedDecl *D = *I;
818 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000819 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
820
821 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
822 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
823 // that's a special case.
824 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
825 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
826 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
827 }
828 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
829 }
830 else
831 hasNonInstance = true;
832 }
833
834 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
835 // member reference.
836 if (Classes.empty())
837 return IMA_Static;
838
839 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
840 // an implicit member reference.
841 if (isStaticContext)
842 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
843
844 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
845 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
846 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
847 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000848 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000849 Classes))
850 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
851
852 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
853}
854
855/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
856static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
857 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
858 const LookupResult &R) {
859 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
860 SourceRange Range(Loc);
861 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
862
863 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
864 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
865 if (MD->isStatic()) {
866 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
867 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
868 << Range << R.getLookupName();
869 return;
870 }
871 }
872
873 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
874 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
875 return;
876 }
877
878 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000879}
880
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
882///
883/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000884bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
885 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000886 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
887
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000888 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000889 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000890 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
891 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000892 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000893 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000894 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
895 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000896
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000897 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
898 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
899 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
900 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000901 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000902 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000903 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
904 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
905
906 if (!R.empty()) {
907 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
908 R.suppressDiagnostics();
909
910 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
911 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
912 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
913 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
914
915 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
916 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
917 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000918 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000919 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
920 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000921 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000922 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000923 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000924 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
925 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
926 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
927 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
928 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
929 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
930 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
931 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
932 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
933 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
934 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
935 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
936 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
937 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000938 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000939 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
940 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
941 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000942 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000943 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000944 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000945 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000946
947 // Do we really want to note all of these?
948 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
949 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
950
951 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
952 return false;
953 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000954
955 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000956 }
957 }
958
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000959 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000960 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000961 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000962 if (!R.empty()) {
963 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
964 if (SS.isEmpty())
965 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
966 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
967 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
968 else
969 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
970 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
971 << SS.getRange()
972 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
973 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
974 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
975 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
976 << ND->getDeclName();
977
978 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
979 return false;
980 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000981
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000982 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
983 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
984 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
985 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
986 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
987 // to recover well anyway.
988 if (SS.isEmpty())
989 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
990 else
991 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
992 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
993 << SS.getRange();
994
995 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
996 return true;
997 }
998 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000999 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001000 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001001 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001002 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001003 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001004 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001005 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1006 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001007 return true;
1008 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001009 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001010 }
1011
1012 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1013 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1014 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1015 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1016 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1017 << SS.getRange();
1018 return true;
1019 }
1020
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001021 // Give up, we can't recover.
1022 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1023 return true;
1024}
1025
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001026static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001027 IdentifierInfo *II,
1028 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001029 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1030 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1031 if (!IDecl)
1032 return 0;
1033 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1034 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1035 return 0;
1036 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1037 if (!property)
1038 return 0;
1039 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1040 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1041 return 0;
1042 return property;
1043}
1044
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001045static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001046 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001047 IdentifierInfo *II,
1048 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1049 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001050 bool LookForIvars;
1051 if (Lookup.empty())
1052 LookForIvars = true;
1053 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1054 LookForIvars = false;
1055 else
1056 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1057 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1058 if (!LookForIvars)
1059 return 0;
1060
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001061 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1062 if (!IDecl)
1063 return 0;
1064 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001065 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1066 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001067 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1068 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1069 if (!property)
1070 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianbfcbc852010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001071 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II)) {
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001072 DynamicImplSeen =
1073 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
Fariborz Jahanianbfcbc852010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001074 // property implementation has a designated ivar. No need to assume a new
1075 // one.
1076 if (!DynamicImplSeen && PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1077 return 0;
1078 }
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001079 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001080 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1081 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001082 NameLoc,
1083 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1084 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1085 (Expr *)0, true);
1086 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1087 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1088 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1089 return Ivar;
1090 }
1091 return 0;
1092}
1093
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001094ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001095 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1096 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1097 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1098 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001099 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1100 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1101
1102 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001103 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001104
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001105 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001106
1107 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001108 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001109 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001110 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001111
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001112 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001113 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001114 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001115
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001116 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1117 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001118 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1119 // (note: handled after lookup)
1120 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1121 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1122 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1124 // names a dependent type.
1125 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1126 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001127 bool DependentID = false;
1128 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1129 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1130 DependentID = true;
1131 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1132 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1133 if (DC) {
1134 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1135 return ExprError();
1136 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1137 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1138 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1139 } else {
1140 DependentID = true;
1141 }
1142 }
1143
1144 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001145 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001146 TemplateArgs);
1147 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001148 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001149 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001150 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001152 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1153 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1154 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1155 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1156 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001157 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1158 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1159 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001160 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001161 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001162 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001163
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001164 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1165 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001166 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001167 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 if (E.isInvalid())
1169 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001170
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001171 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1172 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001173 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1174 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001175 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001176 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1177 isAddressOfOperand);
1178 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001179 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1180 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001181 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001182 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001183
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001184 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1185 return ExprError();
1186
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001187 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1188 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001189 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001190
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001191 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001192 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001193 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1194 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1195 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1196 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1197 }
1198
1199 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1200 // call, diagnose the problem.
1201 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001202 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001203 return ExprError();
1204
1205 assert(!R.empty() &&
1206 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001207
1208 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1209 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001210 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001211 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1212 R.clear();
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001213 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001214 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1215 return move(E);
1216 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001217 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001218 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001219
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001220 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1221 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1222
1223 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001224 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001225 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1226 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001227 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1228 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1229 if (Property) {
1230 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1231 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001232 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001233 }
1234 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001235 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001236 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1237 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1238 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1239 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1240 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1241 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001242 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001243 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001244
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001245 QualType T = Func->getType();
1246 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001247 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001248 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1249 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001250 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001251 }
1252 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001253
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001254 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001255 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1256 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1257 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1258 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1259 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1260 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1261 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1262 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001263 //
1264 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1265 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1266 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1267 // non-static member function:
1268 //
1269 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1270 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1271 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1272 // member function call.
1273 //
1274 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1275 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1276 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1277 // instance method.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001278 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001279 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1280 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1281 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1282 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1283 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1284 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1285 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregor1262b062010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001286 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1287 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001288 else
1289 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1290
1291 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001292 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001293 }
1294
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001295 if (TemplateArgs)
1296 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001297
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001298 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1299}
1300
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001301/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001302ExprResult
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001303Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1304 LookupResult &R,
1305 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1306 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1307 case IMA_Instance:
1308 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1309
1310 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1311 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1312 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1313 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1314
1315 case IMA_Mixed:
1316 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1317 case IMA_Unresolved:
1318 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1319
1320 case IMA_Static:
1321 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1322 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1323 if (TemplateArgs)
1324 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1325 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1326
1327 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1328 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1329 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1330 return ExprError();
1331 }
1332
1333 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1334 return ExprError();
1335}
1336
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001337/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1338/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1339/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1340/// this path.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001341ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001342Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001343 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001344 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001345 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001346 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001347
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001348 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001349 return ExprError();
1350
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001351 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001352 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1353
1354 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1355 return ExprError();
1356
1357 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001358 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1359 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001360 return ExprError();
1361 }
1362
1363 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1364}
1365
1366/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1367/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1368/// additional lookup.
1369///
1370/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1371/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1372///
1373/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001374ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001375Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001376 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001377 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001378 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001379
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001380 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1381 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1382 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1383 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1384 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1385
1386 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1387 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1388 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001389 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001390
1391 bool LookForIvars;
1392 if (Lookup.empty())
1393 LookForIvars = true;
1394 else if (IsClassMethod)
1395 LookForIvars = false;
1396 else
1397 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1398 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001399 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001400 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001401 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001402 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1403 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1404 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1405 if (IsClassMethod)
1406 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1407 << IV->getDeclName());
1408
1409 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1410 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1411 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1412 return ExprError();
1413
1414 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1415 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1416 return ExprError();
1417
1418 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1419 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1420 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1421 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1422
1423 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1424 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1425 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1426 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001427 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001428 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001429 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregora1ed39b2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001430 SelfName, false, false);
1431 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1432 return ExprError();
1433
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001434 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1435 return Owned(new (Context)
1436 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1437 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1438 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001439 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001440 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001441 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001442 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1443 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1444 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1445 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1446 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1447 }
1448 }
1449
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001450 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1451 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1452 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1453 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1454 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1455 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1456 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1457 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1458 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1459 }
1460 }
1461 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001462 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1463 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001464}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001465
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001466/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1467///
1468/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1469///
1470/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1471/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1472/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1473/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1474///
1475/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1476/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1477/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1478/// the class declaring the member.
1479///
1480/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1481/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1482/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001483bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001484Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1485 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001486 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001487 NamedDecl *Member) {
1488 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1489 if (!RD)
1490 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001491
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 QualType DestRecordType;
1493 QualType DestType;
1494 QualType FromRecordType;
1495 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1496 bool PointerConversions = false;
1497 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1498 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001499
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001500 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1501 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1502 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1503 PointerConversions = true;
1504 } else {
1505 DestType = DestRecordType;
1506 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001507 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001508 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1509 if (Method->isStatic())
1510 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001511
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001512 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1513 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001514
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001515 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1516 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1517 PointerConversions = true;
1518 } else {
1519 FromRecordType = FromType;
1520 DestType = DestRecordType;
1521 }
1522 } else {
1523 // No conversion necessary.
1524 return false;
1525 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001526
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001527 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1528 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001529
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001530 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1531 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1532 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001533
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001534 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1535 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1536
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001537 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001538
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001539 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001540 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001541 // class name.
1542 //
1543 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1544 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1545 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1546 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1547 //
1548 // class Base { public: int x; };
1549 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1550 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1551 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1552 //
1553 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1554 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1555 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1556 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001557 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001558 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1559 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1560 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1561
1562 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1563
1564 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1565 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1566 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1567 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001568 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001569 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001570 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001571 return true;
1572
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001573 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001574 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001575 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1576 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001577
1578 FromType = QType;
1579 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1580
1581 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1582 // we're done.
1583 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1584 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001585 }
1586 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001587
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001588 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001589
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001590 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1591 // down to the using declaration's type.
1592 //
1593 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1594 // class ever has member declarations.
1595 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1596 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1597 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1598 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1599
1600 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1601 // conversion is non-trivial.
1602 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1603 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001604 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001605 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001606 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001607 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001608
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001609 QualType UType = URecordType;
1610 if (PointerConversions)
1611 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001612 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001613 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001614 FromType = UType;
1615 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1616 }
1617
1618 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1619 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1620 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001621 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001622
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001623 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001624 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1625 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001626 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001627 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001628
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001629 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001630 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001631 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001632}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001633
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001634/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001635static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001636 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001637 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001638 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1639 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001640 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1641 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1642 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001643 if (SS.isSet()) {
1644 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1645 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001646 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001647
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001648 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001649 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1650 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001651}
1652
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001653/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1654/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1655/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1656/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001657ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001658Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1659 LookupResult &R,
1660 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1661 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001662 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1663
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001664 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001665
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001666 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1667 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001668 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001669 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001670 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001671 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001672 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001673
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001674 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1675 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001676 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1677 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001678 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1679 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001680 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1681 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1682 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1683 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001684 }
1685
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001686 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001687 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1688 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001689 SS,
1690 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1691 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001692}
1693
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001694bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001695 const LookupResult &R,
1696 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001697 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1698 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1699 return false;
1700
1701 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001702 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001703 return false;
1704
1705 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001706 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001707 return false;
1708
1709 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1710 // normal lookup:
1711 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1712 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1713
1714 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1715 // -- a declaration of a class member
1716 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1717 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001718 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001719 return false;
1720
1721 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1722 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1723 // using-declaration
1724 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1725 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1726 // turn off ADL anyway).
1727 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1728 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1729 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1730 return false;
1731
1732 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1733 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1734 // template
1735 // And also for builtin functions.
1736 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1737 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1738
1739 // But also builtin functions.
1740 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1741 return false;
1742 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1743 return false;
1744 }
1745
1746 return true;
1747}
1748
1749
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001750/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1751/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1752/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1753/// will in fact be used.
1754static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1755 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1756 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1757 return true;
1758 }
1759
1760 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1761 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1762 return true;
1763 }
1764
1765 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1766 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1767 return true;
1768 }
1769
1770 return false;
1771}
1772
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001773ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001774Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001775 LookupResult &R,
1776 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001777 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1778 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001779 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001780 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1781 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001782
1783 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1784 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1785 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001786 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1787 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001788 return ExprError();
1789
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001790 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1791 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1792 // we've picked a target.
1793 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1794
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001795 bool Dependent
1796 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001797 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001798 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001799 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001800 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001801 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1802 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001803
1804 return Owned(ULE);
1805}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001806
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001807
1808/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001809ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001810Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001811 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1812 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001813 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001814 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1815 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001816
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001817 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001818 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1819 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001820
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001821 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1822 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1823 // a template argument list.
1824 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1825 << Template << SS.getRange();
1826 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1827 return ExprError();
1828 }
1829
1830 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1831 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1832 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001833 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001834 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001835 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001836 return ExprError();
1837 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001838
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001839 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1840 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1841 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1842 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001843 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001844 return ExprError();
1845
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001846 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1847 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001848 return ExprError();
1849
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001850 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1851 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1852 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1853 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001854 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001855 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1856 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1857 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001858 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001859 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001860 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1861 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1862 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1863 return ExprError();
1864 }
1865
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001866 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001867 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1868 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1869 return ExprError();
1870 }
1871
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001872 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001873 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001874 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001875 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001876 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001877 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1878 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001879 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001880
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001881 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001882 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001883 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1884 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001885 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001886 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1887 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1888 Expr *E = new (Context)
1889 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1890 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001891
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001892 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001893 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001894 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001895 SourceLocation(),
1896 Owned(E));
1897 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001898 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001899 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1900 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1901 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001902 }
1903 }
1904 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001905 }
1906 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1907 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001908
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001909 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1910 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001911}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001912
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001913ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001914 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001915 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001916
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001917 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001918 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001919 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1920 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1921 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001922 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001923
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001924 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1925 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001926
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001927 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001928 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1929 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001930 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001931 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001932 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001933 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001934
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001935 QualType ResTy;
1936 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1937 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1938 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001939 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001940
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001941 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001942 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001943 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1944 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001945 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001946}
1947
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001948ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001949 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001950 bool Invalid = false;
1951 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1952 if (Invalid)
1953 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001954
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001955 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1956 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001957 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001958 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001959
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001960 QualType Ty;
1961 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1962 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1963 else if (Literal.isWide())
1964 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001965 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1966 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001967 else
1968 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001969
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001970 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1971 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001972 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001973}
1974
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001975ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001977 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1978 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001979 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001980 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001981 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001982 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001983 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001984
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001985 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001986 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1987 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001988 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001989
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001990 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001991 bool Invalid = false;
1992 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1993 if (Invalid)
1994 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001995
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001996 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001997 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001998 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001999 return ExprError();
2000
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002001 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002002
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002003 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002004 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002005 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002006 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002007 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002008 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002009 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002010 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002011
2012 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2013
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002014 using llvm::APFloat;
2015 APFloat Val(Format);
2016
2017 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002018
2019 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2020 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2021 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2022 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002023 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002024 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002025 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002026 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002027 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2028 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002029 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002030 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2031 }
2032
2033 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2034 << Ty
2035 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2036 }
2037
2038 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002039 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002040
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002041 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002042 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002043 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002044 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002045
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002046 // long long is a C99 feature.
2047 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002048 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002049 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2050
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002051 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002052 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002053
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002054 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2055 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2056 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002057 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2058 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002059 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002060 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002061 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2062 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002063
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002064 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2065 // be an unsigned int.
2066 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2067
2068 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002069 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002070 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2071 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002072 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002073
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002074 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2075 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2076 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2077 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002078 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002079 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002080 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002081 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002082 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002083 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002084
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002085 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002086 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002087 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002088
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002089 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2090 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2091 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2092 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002093 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002094 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002095 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002096 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002097 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002098 }
2099
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002100 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002101 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002102 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002103
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002104 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2105 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2106 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2107 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002108 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002109 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002110 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002111 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002112 }
2113 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002114
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002115 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2116 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002117 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002118 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002119 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002120 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002121 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002122
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002123 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2124 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002125 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002126 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002127 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002128
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002129 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2130 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002131 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002132 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002133
2134 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002135}
2136
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002137ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002138 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002139 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002140 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002141}
2142
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002143/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002144/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002145bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002146 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002147 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002148 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002149 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2150 return false;
2151
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002152 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2153 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2154 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2155 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2156 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2157 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2158
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002159 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002160 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002161 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002162 if (isSizeof)
2163 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2164 return false;
2165 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002166
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002167 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002168 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002169 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2170 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002171 return false;
2172 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002173
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002174 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002175 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2176 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002177 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002178
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002179 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002180 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002181 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002182 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2183 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002184 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002185
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002186 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002187}
2188
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002189static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2190 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002191 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002192
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002193 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002194 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2195 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002196
2197 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2198 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2199 return false;
2200
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002201 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002202 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002203 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002204 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002205
2206 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2207 // bit-field.
2208 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002209 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002210 return false;
2211
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002212 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002213}
2214
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002215/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002216ExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002217Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002218 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002219 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002220 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002221 return ExprError();
2222
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002223 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002224
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002225 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2226 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2227 return ExprError();
2228
2229 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002230 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002231 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2232 R.getEnd()));
2233}
2234
2235/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2236/// operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002237ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002238Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002239 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2240 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2241 bool isInvalid = false;
2242 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2243 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2244 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002245 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002246 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002247 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2248 isInvalid = true;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002249 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2250 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2251 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2252 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002253 } else {
2254 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2255 }
2256
2257 if (isInvalid)
2258 return ExprError();
2259
2260 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2261 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2262 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2263 R.getEnd()));
2264}
2265
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002266/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2267/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2268/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002269ExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002270Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2271 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002272 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002273 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002274
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002275 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002276 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002277 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002278 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002279 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002280
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002281 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002282 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002283 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2284
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002285 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002286}
2287
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002288QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002289 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2290 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002291
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002292 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002293 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002294 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002295
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002296 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2297 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2298 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002299
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002300 // Test for placeholders.
2301 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2302 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2303 if (PR.take() != V) {
2304 V = PR.take();
2305 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2306 }
2307
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002308 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002309 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2310 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002311 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002312}
2313
2314
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002315
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002316ExprResult
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002317Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002318 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002319 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002320 switch (Kind) {
2321 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002322 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2323 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002324 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002325
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002326 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002327}
2328
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002329ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002330Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2331 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002332 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002333 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002334 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2335 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002336
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002337 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002338
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002339 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002340 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002341 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2342 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2343 }
2344
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002345 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002346 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002347 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2348 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2349 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002350 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002351 }
2352
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002353 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002354}
2355
2356
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002357ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002358Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2359 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2360 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2361 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002362
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002363 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002364 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2365 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2366 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002367
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002368 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002369
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002370 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002371 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002372 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002373 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002374 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2375 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002376 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2377 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2378 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2379 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002380 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002381 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2382 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002383 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002384 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002385 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002386 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2387 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002388 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002389 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002390 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002391 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2392 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2393 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002394 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002395 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002396 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2397 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2398 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2399 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002400 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002401 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002402 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002403
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002404 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2405 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002406 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2407 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002408 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002409 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2410 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2411 // force the promotion here.
2412 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2413 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002414 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002415 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002416 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2417
2418 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2419 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002420 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002421 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2422 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2423 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2424 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002425 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002426 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002427 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2428
2429 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2430 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002431 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002432 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002433 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2434 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002435 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002436 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002437 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002438 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2439 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002440
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002441 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002442 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2443 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002444 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2445
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002446 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002447 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2448 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002449 // incomplete types are not object types.
2450 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2451 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2452 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2453 return ExprError();
2454 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002455
Abramo Bagnara3aabb4b2010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002456 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2457 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2458 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2459 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2460 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002461 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002462 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2463 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002464 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002465
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002466 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002467 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002468 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2469 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2470 return ExprError();
2471 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002472
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002473 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002474 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002475}
2476
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002477QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002478CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002479 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002480 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002481 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2482 // see FIXME there.
2483 //
2484 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2485 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002486 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002487
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002488 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002489 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002490
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002491 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002492 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2493 // to be selected.
2494 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002495
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002496 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2497 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002498 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002499
2500 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2501 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002502 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002503 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2504 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002505 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002506 do
2507 compStr++;
2508 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002509 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002510 do
2511 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002512 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002513 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002514
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002515 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002516 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2517 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002518 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002519 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002520 return QualType();
2521 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002522
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002523 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2524 // operates on.
2525 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002526 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002527
2528 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002529 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002530
2531 while (*compStr) {
2532 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2533 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2534 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2535 return QualType();
2536 }
2537 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002538 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002539
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002540 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002541 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002542 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002543 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002544 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002545 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002546 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002547 if (HexSwizzle)
2548 CompSize--;
2549
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002550 if (CompSize == 1)
2551 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002552
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002553 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002554 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002555 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2556 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2557 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2558 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002559 }
2560 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002561}
2562
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002563static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002564 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002565 const Selector &Sel,
2566 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002567 if (Member)
2568 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2569 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002570 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002571 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002572
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002573 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2574 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002575 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2576 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002577 return D;
2578 }
2579 return 0;
2580}
2581
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002582static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2583 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2584 const Selector &Sel,
2585 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002586 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2587 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002588 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002589 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002590 if (Member)
2591 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2592 GDecl = PD;
2593 break;
2594 }
2595 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002596 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002597 GDecl = OMD;
2598 break;
2599 }
2600 }
2601 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002602 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002603 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2604 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002605 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2606 Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002607 if (GDecl)
2608 return GDecl;
2609 }
2610 }
2611 return GDecl;
2612}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002613
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002614ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002615Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002616 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002617 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2618 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002619 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002620 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002621 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2622 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2623 //
2624 // T* t;
2625 // t.f;
2626 //
2627 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2628 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2629 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2630 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002631 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002632 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2633 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002634 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002635 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002636 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002637 return ExprError();
2638 }
2639 }
2640
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002641 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2642 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002643 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002644
2645 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2646 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002647 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002648 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002649 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002650 SS.getRange(),
2651 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002652 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002653}
2654
2655/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2656/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2657/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2658static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2659 Expr *BaseExpr,
2660 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002661 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002662 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002663 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2664 // diagnostics.
2665 if (!BaseExpr)
2666 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002667
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002668 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2669 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002670}
2671
2672// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2673// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2674// type. The restriction here is:
2675//
2676// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2677// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2678// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2679//
2680// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2681// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2682// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2683// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2684bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2685 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002686 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002687 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002688 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2689 if (!BaseRT) {
2690 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2691 // dependent.
2692 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2693 return false;
2694 }
2695 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002696
2697 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002698 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2699 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002700 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002701 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002702
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002703 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002704 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2705 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2706 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002707
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002708 if (!DC->isRecord())
2709 continue;
2710
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002711 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002712 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002713
2714 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2715 return false;
2716 }
2717
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002718 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002719 return true;
2720}
2721
2722static bool
2723LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2724 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002725 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2726 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002727 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2728 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002729 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002730 << BaseRange))
2731 return true;
2732
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002733 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2734 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2735 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2736
2737 bool MOUS;
2738 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2739 return false;
2740 }
2741
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002742 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2743 if (SS.isSet()) {
2744 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2745 // nested-name-specifier.
2746 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2747
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002748 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002749 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2750 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2751 return true;
2752 }
2753
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002754 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002755
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002756 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2757 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2758 << DC << SS.getRange();
2759 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002760 }
2761 }
2762
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002763 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2764 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002765
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002766 if (!R.empty())
2767 return false;
2768
2769 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2770 // for typos.
2771 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002772 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002773 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002774 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2775 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2776 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002777 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2778 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002779 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2780 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2781 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002782 return false;
2783 } else {
2784 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002785 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002786 }
2787
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002788 return false;
2789}
2790
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002791ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002792Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002793 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002794 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002795 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002796 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002797 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002798 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2799 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002800 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002801 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2802 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002803 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002804
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002805 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002806
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002807 // Implicit member accesses.
2808 if (!Base) {
2809 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2810 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2811 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2812 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002813 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002814 return ExprError();
2815
2816 // Explicit member accesses.
2817 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002818 ExprResult Result =
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002819 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002820 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002821
2822 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2823 Owned(Base);
2824 return ExprError();
2825 }
2826
2827 if (Result.get())
2828 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002829
2830 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2831 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002832 }
2833
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002834 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002835 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2836 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002837}
2838
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002839ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002840Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002841 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2842 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002843 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002844 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002845 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2846 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002847 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002848 if (IsArrow) {
2849 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2850 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2851 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002852 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002853
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002854 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002855 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2856 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2857 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002858
2859 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002860 return ExprError();
2861
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002862 if (R.empty()) {
2863 // Rederive where we looked up.
2864 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2865 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2866 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002867
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002868 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002869 << MemberName << DC
2870 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002871 return ExprError();
2872 }
2873
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002874 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2875 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2876 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2877 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2878 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2879 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2880 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2881 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2882 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2883 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002884 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002885 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002886 return ExprError();
2887
2888 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2889 // result.
2890 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002891 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002892 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002893 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002894 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002895
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002896 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2897 // pick a member.
2898 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2899
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002900 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2901 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2902 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002903 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2904 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002905 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002906 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002907 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002908
2909 return Owned(MemExpr);
2910 }
2911
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002912 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002913 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002914 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2915
2916 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2917
2918 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2919 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2920 // error cases.
2921 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2922 return ExprError();
2923
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002924 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2925 if (!BaseExpr) {
2926 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002927 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002928 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002929
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002930 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2931 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2932 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2933 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002934 }
2935
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002936 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2937 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2938 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2939 // explicitly qualified.
2940 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2941 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2942 }
2943
2944 // Check the use of this member.
2945 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2946 Owned(BaseExpr);
2947 return ExprError();
2948 }
2949
2950 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2951 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2952 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002953 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2954 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002955 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2956 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2957
2958 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2959 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2960 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2961 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2962 else {
2963 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2964 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2965 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2966
2967 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2968 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2969
2970 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2971 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2972 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2973 }
2974
2975 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002976 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002977 return ExprError();
2978 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002979 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2980 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002981 }
2982
2983 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2984 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2985 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002986 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002987 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2988 }
2989
2990 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2991 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2992 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002993 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002994 MemberFn->getType()));
2995 }
2996
2997 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2998 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2999 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003000 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3001 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003002 }
3003
3004 Owned(BaseExpr);
3005
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003006 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003007 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003008 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003009 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3010 else
3011 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3012 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003013
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003014 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3015 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003016 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003017 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003018}
3019
3020/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3021/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3022/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3023/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3024/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3025/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3026/// an ordinary member expression.
3027///
3028/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3029/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003030ExprResult
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003031Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003032 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003033 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003034 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003035 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003036
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003037 // Perform default conversions.
3038 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003039
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003040 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003041 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3042
3043 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3044 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003045
3046 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003047 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003048 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3049 // call, and continue on.
3050 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3051 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3052 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3053 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3054 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003055 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3056 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003057 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3058 ->isRecordType()))) {
3059 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
Nick Lewyckyc60d6e72010-10-15 21:43:24 +00003060 Diag(BaseExpr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003061 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003062 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003063
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003064 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003065 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003066 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003067 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003068 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003069
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003070 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3071 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3072 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3073 }
3074 }
3075 }
3076
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003077 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3078 // use that.
3079 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003080 if (IsArrow) {
3081 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3082 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3083 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003084 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003085 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003086 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3087 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003088 }
3089 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003090 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3091 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3092 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3093 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003094 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003095 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003096 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003097
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003098 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3099 // use that.
3100 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3101 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3102 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3103 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3104 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003105 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003106 }
3107 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003108
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003109 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003110
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003111 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003112 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003113 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3114 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3115 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3116 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3117 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3118 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3119 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3120 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3121 // Check the use of this method.
3122 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3123 return ExprError();
3124 }
3125 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3126 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3127 Selector SetterSel =
3128 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3129 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3130 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3131 if (!Setter) {
3132 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3133 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003134 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003135 }
3136 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3137 if (!Setter)
3138 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003139
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003140 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3141 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003142
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003143 if (Getter || Setter) {
3144 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003145
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003146 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003147 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003148 else
3149 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3150 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3151 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003152 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003153 PType,
3154 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3155 }
3156 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3157 << MemberName << BaseType);
3158 }
3159 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003160
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003161 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3162 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3163 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003164 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003165 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003166
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003167 if (IsArrow) {
3168 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003169 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003170 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3171 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003172 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3173 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3174 // struct MyRecord foo;
3175 // foo->bar
3176 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3177 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3178 // by now.
3179 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3180 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003181 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003182 IsArrow = false;
3183 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003184 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3185 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3186 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003187 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003188 } else {
3189 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3190 // type *foo;
3191 // foo.bar
3192 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3193 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3194 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3195 // the appropriate pointer type
3196 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3197 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3198 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3199 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3200 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003201 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003202 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3203 IsArrow = true;
3204 }
3205 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003206 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003207
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003208 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003209 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003210 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003211 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003212 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003213 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003214 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003215
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003216 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3217 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003218 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003219 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003220 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003221 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3222 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3223 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3224 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003225 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3226
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003227 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003228 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003229
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003230 if (!IV) {
3231 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3232 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3233 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003234 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003235 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003236 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003237 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3238 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003239 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3240 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003241 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003242 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003243 } else {
3244 Res.clear();
3245 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003246 }
3247 }
3248
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003249 if (IV) {
3250 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3251 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3252 // error cases.
3253 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3254 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003255
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003256 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3257 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3258 return ExprError();
3259 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3260 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3261 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3262 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3263 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3264 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3265 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3266 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3267 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3268 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3269 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3270 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003271 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003272 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003273 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3274 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003275 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003276 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3277 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003278
3279 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3280 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003281 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003282 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003283 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003284 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3285 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003286 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003287 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003288 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003289
3290 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3291 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003292 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003293 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003294 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003295 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003296 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003297 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003298 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003299 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003300 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3301 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003302 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003303 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003304
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003305 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003306 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003307 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3308 Context)) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003309 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3310 // Check the use of this declaration
3311 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3312 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003313
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003314 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003315 MemberLoc,
3316 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003317 }
3318 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3319 // Check the use of this method.
3320 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3321 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003322 Selector SetterSel =
3323 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3324 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3325 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3326 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3327 SetterSel, Context))
3328 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3329 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3330 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3331 SMD,
3332 MemberLoc,
3333 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003334 }
3335 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003336
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003337 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003338 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003339 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003340
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003341 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3342 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003343 if (!IsArrow)
3344 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3345 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003346 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc,
3347 SourceLocation(), QualType(), false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003348
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003349 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003350 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003351 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3352 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003353 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003354 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003355 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003356
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003357 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003358 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003359 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003360 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3361 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003362 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003363 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003364 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003365 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003366
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003367 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3368 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3369
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003370 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003371}
3372
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003373/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3374/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3375/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3376/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3377/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3378///
3379/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3380/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3381/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3382/// only be called
3383/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3384/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3385/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003386ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003387 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3388 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003389 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003390 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003391 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003392 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3393 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3394 return ExprError();
3395
3396 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3397
3398 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003399 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003400 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3401 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003402 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003403
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003404 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003405 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3406
3407 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3408 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3409 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3410
3411 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003412 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003413 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3414 Base = Result.take();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003415
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003416 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3417 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003418 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003419 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3420 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003421 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003422 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003423 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003424 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3425 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003426
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003427 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3428 Owned(Base);
3429 return ExprError();
3430 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003431
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003432 if (Result.get()) {
3433 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3434 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3435 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3436 // call now.
3437 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3438 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003439 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003440
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003441 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003442 }
3443
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003444 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003445 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3446 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003447 }
3448
3449 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003450}
3451
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003452ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003453 FunctionDecl *FD,
3454 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3455 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003456 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003457 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3458 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003459 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003460 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003461 return ExprError();
3462 }
3463
3464 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3465 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003466
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003467 // Instantiate the expression.
3468 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3469 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003470
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003471 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3472 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3473 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3474 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003475
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003476 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3477 if (Result.isInvalid())
3478 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003479
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003480 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3481 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003482 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003483 InitializationKind Kind
3484 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3485 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3486 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003487
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003488 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3489 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3490 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3491 if (Result.isInvalid())
3492 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003493
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003494 // Build the default argument expression.
3495 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3496 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003497 }
3498
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003499 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3500 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3501 // be properly destroyed.
3502 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3503 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003504 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3505 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3506 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3507 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3508 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3509 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003510
3511 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003512 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3513 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003514 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003515 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003516}
3517
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003518/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3519/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3520/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3521/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3522/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3523/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003524bool
3525Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003526 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003527 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003528 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3529 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003530 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003531 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3532 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003533 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003534
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003535 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3536 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3537 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3538 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3539 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003540 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003541 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003542 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003543 }
3544
3545 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3546 // them.
3547 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3548 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3549 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3550 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003551 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003552 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003553 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3554 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3555 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003556 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003557 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003558 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003559 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003560 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003561 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003562 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3563 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3564 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3565 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3566 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003567 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003568 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003569 if (Invalid)
3570 return true;
3571 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3572 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3573 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003574
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003575 return false;
3576}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003577
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003578bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3579 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3580 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3581 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3582 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3583 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003584 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003585 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3586 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3587 bool Invalid = false;
3588 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3589 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3590 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3591 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003592 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003593 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003594 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003595
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003596 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003597 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3598 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003599
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003600 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3601 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003602 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003603 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003604 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003605
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003606 // Pass the argument
3607 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3608 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3609 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003610
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003611 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003612 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3613 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003614 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003615 SourceLocation(),
3616 Owned(Arg));
3617 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3618 return true;
3619
3620 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003621 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003622 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003623
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003624 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003625 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003626 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3627 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003628
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003629 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003630 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003631 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003632 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003633
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003634 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003635 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003636 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003637 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003638 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003639 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003640 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003641 }
3642 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003643 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003644}
3645
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003646/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003647/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3648/// locations.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003649ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003650Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003651 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003652 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003653
3654 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003655 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003656 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3657 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003658
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003659 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003660
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003661 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003662 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3663 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3664 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3665 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3666 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003667 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003668 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3669 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003670
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003671 NumArgs = 0;
3672 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003673
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003674 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3675 RParenLoc));
3676 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003677
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003678 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003679 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003680 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3681 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003682 bool Dependent = false;
3683 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3684 Dependent = true;
3685 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3686 Dependent = true;
3687
3688 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003689 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003690 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3691
3692 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3693 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3694 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003695 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003696
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003697 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3698
3699 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3700 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3701 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3702 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3703 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3704 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3705 // method template.
3706 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003707 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3708 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003709 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003710
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003711 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003712 RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003713 }
3714
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003715 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003716 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003717 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003718 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003719 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003720 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003721 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003722
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003723 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003724 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003725 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3726 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003727 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3728 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003729 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003730
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003731 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3732 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3733 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3734 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003735
3736 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3737 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003738 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003739 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003740
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003741 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003742 RParenLoc))
3743 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003744
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003745 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003746 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003747 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003748 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3749 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003750 }
3751 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003752 }
3753
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003754 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003755 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003756 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003757
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003758 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003759 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3760 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003761 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003762 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003763 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003764
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003765 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3766 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3767 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3768
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003769 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3770}
3771
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003772/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3773/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003774/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3775/// block-pointer type.
3776///
3777/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003778ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003779Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3780 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3781 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3782 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3783 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3784
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003785 // Promote the function operand.
3786 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3787
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003788 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3789 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003790 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3791 Args, NumArgs,
3792 Context.BoolTy,
3793 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003794
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003795 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3796 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3797 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3798 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003799 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003800 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003801 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3802 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003803 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003804 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003805 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003806 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003807 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003808 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003809 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3810 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3811
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003812 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003813 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003814 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003815 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003816 return ExprError();
3817
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003818 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003819 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003820
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003821 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003822 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003823 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003824 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003825 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003826 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003827
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003828 if (FDecl) {
3829 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3830 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3831 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003832 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003833 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003834 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003835 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3836 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3837 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3838 }
3839 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003840 }
3841
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003842 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003843 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3844 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3845 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003846 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3847 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003848 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3849 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003850 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003851 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003852 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003853 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003854
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003855 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3856 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003857 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3858 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003859
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003860 // Check for sentinels
3861 if (NDecl)
3862 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003863
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003864 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003865 if (FDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003866 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003867 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003868
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003869 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003870 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003871 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003872 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003873 return ExprError();
3874 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003875
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003876 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003877}
3878
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003879ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003880Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003881 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003882 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003883 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003884 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003885
3886 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3887 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3888 if (!TInfo)
3889 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3890
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003891 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003892}
3893
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003894ExprResult
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003895Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003896 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003897 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003898
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003899 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003900 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003901 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3902 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003903 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3904 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003905 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003906 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003907 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003908 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003909
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003910 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003911 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003912 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003913 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003914 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003915 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003916 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003917 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003918 &literalType);
3919 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003920 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003921 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003922
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003923 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003924 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003925 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003926 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003927 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003928
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003929 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003930 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003931}
3932
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003933ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003934Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003935 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3936 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003937 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003938
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003939 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003940 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003941
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003942 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3943 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003944 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003945 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003946}
3947
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003948static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003949 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003950 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003951 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003952
3953 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3954 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003955 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003956 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3957 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003958 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003959 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003960 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003961
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003962 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3963 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003964 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003965 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003966 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003967 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003968 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003969 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003970
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003971 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3972 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003973 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003974 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003975 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003976 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003977
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003978 // FIXME: Assert here.
3979 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003980 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003981}
3982
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003983/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003984bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003985 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003986 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003987 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003988 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003989 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3990 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003991
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003992 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003993
3994 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3995 // type needs to be scalar.
3996 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3997 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003998 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003999 return false;
4000 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004001
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00004002 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
4003 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
4004 return true;
4005
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004006 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004007 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004008 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4009 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004010 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004011 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4012 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004013 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004014 return false;
4015 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004016
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004017 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004018 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004019 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004020 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004021 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004022 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004023 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara5d3e7242010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004024 castExpr->getType()) &&
4025 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004026 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4027 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4028 break;
4029 }
4030 }
4031 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4032 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4033 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004034 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004035 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004036 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004037
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004038 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4039 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4040 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4041 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004042
4043 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004044 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004045 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4046 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004047 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004048 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004049
4050 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004051 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004052
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004053 if (castType->isVectorType())
4054 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4055 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4056 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4057
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004058 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4059 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004060
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004061 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004062 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004063 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004064 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004065 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4066 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4067 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4068 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004069 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004070 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4071 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4072 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004073 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004074
4075 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004076
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004077 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004078 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4079
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004080 return false;
4081}
4082
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004083bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004084 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004085 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004086
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004087 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004088 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004089 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004090 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004091 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004092 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004093 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004094 } else
4095 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004096 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004097 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004098
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004099 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004100 return false;
4101}
4102
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004103bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004104 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004105 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004106
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004107 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004108
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004109 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4110 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004111 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4112 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4113 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4114 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004115 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004116 return false;
4117 }
4118
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004119 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004120 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4121 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004122 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4123 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4124 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4125 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004126
4127 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4128 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4129 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004130
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004131 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004132 return false;
4133}
4134
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004135ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004136Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004137 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4138 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004139 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004140
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004141 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4142 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4143 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004144 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004145
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004146 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4147 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004148 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004149 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004150
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004151 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004152}
4153
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004154ExprResult
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004155Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004156 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004157 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004158 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004159 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004160 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004161 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004162
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004163 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004164 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004165 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4166 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004167}
4168
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004169/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4170/// of comma binary operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004171ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004172Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004173 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4174 if (!E)
4175 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004176
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004177 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004178
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004179 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004180 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4181 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004182
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004183 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4184
4185 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004186}
4187
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004188ExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004189Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004190 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004191 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004192 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004193 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004194 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004195
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004196 // Check for an altivec literal,
4197 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004198 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4199 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4200 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4201 return ExprError();
4202 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004203 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4204 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4205 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4206 }
4207 else
4208 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4209 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004210
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004211 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4212 // then handle it as such.
4213 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004214 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4215 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4216 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4217
4218 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4219 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004220 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4221 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004222 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4223 E->setType(Ty);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004224 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004225 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004226 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004227 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004228 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004229 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4230 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004231 }
4232}
4233
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004234ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004235 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004236 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004237 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004238 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4239 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004240 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4241 Expr *expr;
4242 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4243 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4244 else
4245 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004246 return Owned(expr);
4247}
4248
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004249/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4250/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004251/// C99 6.5.15
4252QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004253 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004254 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004255 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4256 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004257 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004258
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004259 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004260 if (SAVE) {
4261 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4262 }
4263 else
4264 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004265 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4266 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4267 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4268 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004269
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004270 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004271 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004272 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4273 // Throw an error if its not either.
4274 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4275 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4276 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4277 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4278 << CondTy;
4279 return QualType();
4280 }
4281 }
4282 else {
4283 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4284 << CondTy;
4285 return QualType();
4286 }
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004287 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004288
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004289 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004290 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4291 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004292
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004293 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4294 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4295 // built in select.
4296 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4297 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4298 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4299 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4300 << CondTy;
4301 return QualType();
4302 }
4303 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4304 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4305 << CondTy;
4306 return QualType();
4307 }
4308 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4309 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4310 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4311 }
4312
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004313 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4314 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004315 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4316 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4317 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004318 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004319
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004320 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4321 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004322 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4323 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004324 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004325 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004326 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004327 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004328 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004329 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004330
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004331 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004332 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004333 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4334 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4335 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4336 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4337 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4338 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4339 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004340 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4341 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004342 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004343 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004344 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4345 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004346 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004347 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004348 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004349 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004350 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004351 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004352 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004353 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004354 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004355 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004356 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004357
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004358 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4359 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4360 QuestionLoc);
4361 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4362 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004363
4364
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004365 // Handle block pointer types.
4366 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4367 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4368 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4369 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004370 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4371 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004372 return destType;
4373 }
4374 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004375 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004376 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004377 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004378 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4379 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4380 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004381 return LHSTy;
4382 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004383 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004384 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4385 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004386
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004387 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4388 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004389 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004390 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004391 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4392 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4393 // to get a consistent AST.
4394 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004395 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4396 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004397 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004398 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004399 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004400 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4401 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004402 return LHSTy;
4403 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004404
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004405 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4406 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4407 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004408 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4409 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004410
4411 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4412 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4413 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004414 QualType destPointee
4415 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004416 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004417 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004418 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004419 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004420 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004421 return destType;
4422 }
4423 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004424 QualType destPointee
4425 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004426 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004427 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004428 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004429 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004430 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004431 return destType;
4432 }
4433
4434 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4435 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4436 return LHSTy;
4437 }
4438 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4439 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4440 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4441 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4442 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4443 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4444 // to get a consistent AST.
4445 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004446 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4447 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004448 return incompatTy;
4449 }
4450 // The pointer types are compatible.
4451 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4452 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4453 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4454 // type.
4455 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4456 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004457 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4458 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004459 return LHSTy;
4460 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004461
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004462 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4463 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4464 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4465 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004466 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004467 return RHSTy;
4468 }
4469 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4470 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4471 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004472 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004473 return LHSTy;
4474 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004475
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004476 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004477 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4478 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004479 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004480}
4481
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004482/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4483/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4484QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4485 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4486 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4487 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004488
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004489 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4490 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4491 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4492 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4493 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004494 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004495 return LHSTy;
4496 }
4497 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4498 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004499 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004500 return RHSTy;
4501 }
4502 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4503 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4504 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004505 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004506 return LHSTy;
4507 }
4508 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4509 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004510 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004511 return RHSTy;
4512 }
4513 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4514 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4515 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004516 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004517 return LHSTy;
4518 }
4519 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4520 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004521 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004522 return RHSTy;
4523 }
4524 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4525 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004526
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004527 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4528 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4529 return LHSTy;
4530 }
4531 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4532 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4533 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004534
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004535 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4536 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4537 // type. This allows
4538 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4539 // where B is a subclass of A.
4540 //
4541 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4542 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4543 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4544 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004545
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004546 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4547 // It could return the composite type.
4548 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4549 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4550 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4551 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4552 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4553 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4554 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4555 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4556 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4557 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4558 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4559 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4560 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4561 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004562 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004563 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4564 ;
4565 else {
4566 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4567 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4568 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4569 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004570 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4571 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004572 return incompatTy;
4573 }
4574 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004575 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4576 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004577 return compositeType;
4578 }
4579 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4580 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4581 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4582 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4583 QualType destPointee
4584 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4585 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4586 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004587 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004588 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004589 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004590 return destType;
4591 }
4592 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4593 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4594 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4595 QualType destPointee
4596 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4597 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4598 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004599 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004600 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004601 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004602 return destType;
4603 }
4604 return QualType();
4605}
4606
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004607/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004608/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004609ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004610 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004611 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4612 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004613 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4614 // was the condition.
4615 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004616 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4617 if (isLHSNull) {
4618 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4619 }
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004620
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004621 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4622 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004623 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004624 return ExprError();
4625
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004626 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004627 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4628 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4629 result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004630}
4631
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004632// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004633// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004634// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4635// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4636// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004637Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004638Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004639 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004640
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004641 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4642 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4643 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4644 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4645 return Compatible;
4646 }
4647
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004648 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004649 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4650 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004651
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004652 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004653 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4654 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004655
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004656 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004657
4658 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4659 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4660 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004661 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004662 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004663 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004664
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004665 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4666 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004667 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004668 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004669 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004670 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004671
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004672 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004673 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4674 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004675 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004676
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004677 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004678 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004679 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004680
4681 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004682 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4683 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004684 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004685 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004686 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004687 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4688 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4689 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4690 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4691 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4692 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004693 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004694 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004695 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004696 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004697
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004698 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004699 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004700 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004701 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004702
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004703 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4704 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4705 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4706 // warning can be disabled.
4707 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4708 return ConvTy;
4709 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4710 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004711
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004712 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4713 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4714 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4715 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4716 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4717 do {
4718 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4719 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004720
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004721 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4722 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4723 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004724
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004725 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004726 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004727 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004728
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004729 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004730 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004731 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004732 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004733}
4734
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004735/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4736/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4737/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4738// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004739Sema::AssignConvertType
4740Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004741 QualType rhsType) {
4742 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004743
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004744 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004745 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4746 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004747
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004748 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4749 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4750 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004751
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004752 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004753
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004754 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004755 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004756 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004757
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004758 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4759 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4760 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4761 }
4762 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004763 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004764 return ConvTy;
4765}
4766
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004767/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4768/// for assignment compatibility.
4769Sema::AssignConvertType
4770Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004771 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4772 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004773 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4774 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004775 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004776 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004777 }
4778 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4779 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004780 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4781 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004782 return IncompatiblePointer;
4783 return Compatible;
4784 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004785 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004786 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004787 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004788 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4789 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4790 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4791 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4792 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4793 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004794
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004795 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4796 return Compatible;
4797 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4798 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004799 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004800}
4801
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004802/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4803/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004804/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4805///
4806/// int a, *pint;
4807/// short *pshort;
4808/// struct foo *pfoo;
4809///
4810/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4811/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4812/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4813/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4814///
4815/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004816/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004817///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004818Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004819Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004820 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4821 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004822 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4823 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004824
4825 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004826 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004827
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004828 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4829 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4830 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4831 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4832 return Compatible;
4833 }
4834
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004835 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4836 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4837 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4838 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4839 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4840 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4841 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004842 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004843 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004844 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004845 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004846 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004847 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4848 // to the same ExtVector type.
4849 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4850 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4851 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004852 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004853 return Compatible;
4854 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004855
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004856 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004857 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4858 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4859 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4860 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4861 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4862 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004863 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004864
4865 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4866 // vector type and vice versa
4867 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4868 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004869 }
4870 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004871 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004872
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004873 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4874 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004875 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004876
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004877 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004878 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004879 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004880
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004881 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004882 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004883
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004884 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004885 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004886 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4887 return Compatible;
4888 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004889 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004890 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4891 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004892 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004893
4894 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004895 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004896 return Compatible;
4897 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004898 return Incompatible;
4899 }
4900
4901 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4902 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004903 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004904
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004905 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004906 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004907 return Compatible;
4908
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004909 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4910 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004911
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004912 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004913 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004914 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004915 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004916 return Incompatible;
4917 }
4918
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004919 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4920 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4921 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004922
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004923 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004924 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004925 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4926 return Compatible;
4927 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004928 }
4929 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004930 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004931 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004932 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004933 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4934 return Compatible;
4935 }
4936 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4937 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4938 return Compatible;
4939 return Incompatible;
4940 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004941 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004942 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004943 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4944 return Compatible;
4945
4946 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004947 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004948
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004949 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004950 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004951
4952 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004953 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004954 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004955 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004956 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004957 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4958 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4959 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4960 return Compatible;
4961
4962 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4963 return PointerToInt;
4964
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004965 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004966 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004967 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4968 return Compatible;
4969 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004970 }
4971 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004972 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004973 return Compatible;
4974 return Incompatible;
4975 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004976
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004977 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004978 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004979 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004980 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004981 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004982}
4983
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004984/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4985/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004986static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004987 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4988 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4989 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004990 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004991 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004992 SourceLocation());
4993 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4994 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4995
4996 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4997 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004998 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004999 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005000 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005001}
5002
5003Sema::AssignConvertType
5004Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
5005 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
5006
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005007 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005008 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5009 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005010 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005011 return Incompatible;
5012
5013 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5014 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5015 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5016 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005017 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5018 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005019 it != itend; ++it) {
5020 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5021 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5022 // 1) void pointer
5023 // 2) null pointer constant
5024 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005025 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005026 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005027 InitField = *it;
5028 break;
5029 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005030
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005031 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005032 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005033 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005034 InitField = *it;
5035 break;
5036 }
5037 }
5038
5039 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5040 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar60785eb2010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005041 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005042 InitField = *it;
5043 break;
5044 }
5045 }
5046
5047 if (!InitField)
5048 return Incompatible;
5049
5050 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5051 return Compatible;
5052}
5053
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005054Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005055Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005056 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5057 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5058 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5059 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5060 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005061 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005062 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005063 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005064 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005065 }
5066
5067 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5068 // structures.
5069 }
5070
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005071 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5072 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005073 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5074 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005075 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005076 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005077 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005078 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005079 return Compatible;
5080 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005081
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005082 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005083 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005084 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005085 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005086 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005087 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005088 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005089 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005090
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005091 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5092 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005093
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005094 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5095 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005096 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5097 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5098 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5099 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005100 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005101 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005102 CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005103 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005104}
5105
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005106QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005107 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005108 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005109 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005110 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005111}
5112
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005113QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005114 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005115 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005116 QualType lhsType =
5117 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5118 QualType rhsType =
5119 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005120
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005121 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005122 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005123 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005124
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005125 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5126 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005127 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005128 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005129 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005130 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005131 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005132 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005133 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005134 return lhsType;
5135 }
5136
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005137 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005138 return rhsType;
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005139 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5140 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5141 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5142 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5143 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5144 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005145 }
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005146 }
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005147 }
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005148 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005149
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005150 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5151 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5152 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005153 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005154 return rhsType;
5155 }
5156
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005157 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5158 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5159 bool swapped = false;
5160 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5161 swapped = true;
5162 std::swap(rex, lex);
5163 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5164 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005165
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005166 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005167 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005168 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005169 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005170 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005171 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005172 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5173 return lhsType;
5174 }
5175 }
5176 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5177 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5178 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005179 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005180 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5181 return lhsType;
5182 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005183 }
5184 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005185
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005186 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005187 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005188 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005189 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005190 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005191}
5192
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005193QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5194 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005195 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005196 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005197
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005198 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005199
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005200 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5201 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5202 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005203
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005204 // Check for division by zero.
5205 if (isDiv &&
5206 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005207 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005208 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005209
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005210 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005211}
5212
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005213QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005214 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005215 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005216 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5217 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005218 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5219 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5220 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005221
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005222 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005223
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005224 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5225 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005226
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005227 // Check for remainder by zero.
5228 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005229 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5230 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005231
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005232 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005233}
5234
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005235QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005236 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005237 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5238 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5239 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5240 return compType;
5241 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005242
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005243 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005244
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005245 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005246 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5247 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5248 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005249 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005250 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005251
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005252 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5253 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005254 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005255 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5256
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005257 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005258
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005259 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005260 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005261
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005262 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5263 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005264 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5265 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005266 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005267 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005268 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005269
5270 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5271 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5272 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005273 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005274 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5275 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5276 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5277 return QualType();
5278 }
5279
5280 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5281 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5282 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005283 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005284 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005285 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005286 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005287 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5288 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005289 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5290 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005291 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005292 return QualType();
5293 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005294 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005295 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005296 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5297 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5298 return QualType();
5299 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005300
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005301 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005302 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5303 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5304 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5305 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5306 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005307 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005308 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5309 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005310 return PExp->getType();
5311 }
5312 }
5313
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005314 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005315}
5316
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005317// C99 6.5.6
5318QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005319 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5320 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5321 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5322 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5323 return compType;
5324 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005325
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005326 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005327
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005328 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005329
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005330 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005331 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5332 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005333 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005334 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005335 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005336
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005337 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005338 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005339 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005340
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005341 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005342
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005343 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5344 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5345 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5346 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5347 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5348 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5349 return QualType();
5350 }
5351
5352 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5353 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5354 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5355 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5356 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005357 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005358 return QualType();
5359 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005360
5361 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5362 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5363 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005364 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005365 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005366 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005367 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005368 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005369
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005370 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005371 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005372 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5373 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5374 return QualType();
5375 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005376
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005377 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005378 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5379 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5380 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5381 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5382 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5383 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005384 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005385 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5386
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005387 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005388 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005389 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005390
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005391 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005392 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005393 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005394
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005395 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5396 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5397 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5398 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5399 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5400 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5401 return QualType();
5402 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005403
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005404 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5405 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5406 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5407 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005408 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005409 return QualType();
5410 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005411
5412 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5413 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5414 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5415 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5416 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005417 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5418 << rex->getSourceRange()
5419 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005420 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005421
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005422 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5423 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5424 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5425 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5426 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5427 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5428 return QualType();
5429 }
5430 } else {
5431 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5432 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5433 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5434 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5435 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5436 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5437 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5438 return QualType();
5439 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005440 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005441
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005442 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5443 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5444 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5445 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5446 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005447 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005448 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005449
5450 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005451 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5452 }
5453 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005454
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005455 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005456}
5457
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005458static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5459 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5460 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5461 return false;
5462}
5463
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005464// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005465QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005466 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005467 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005468 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5469 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005470 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005471
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005472 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5473 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5474 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5475 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5476 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5477 }
5478
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005479 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5480 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5481 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5482
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005483 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5484 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005485 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5486 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5487 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5488 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5489 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005490 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005491 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005492 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005493
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005494 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005495
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005496 // Sanity-check shift operands
5497 llvm::APSInt Right;
5498 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005499 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5500 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005501 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005502 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5503 else {
5504 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5505 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5506 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5507 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5508 }
5509 }
5510
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005511 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005512 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005513}
5514
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005515static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5516 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5517 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5518 return true;
5519 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5520 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5521 }
5522 return false;
5523}
5524
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005525// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005526QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005527 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005528 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005529
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005530 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005531 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005532 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005533
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005534 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5535 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005536
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005537 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005538 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5539 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5540 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005541 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5542 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5543 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005544 //
5545 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5546 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5547 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5548 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5549 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5550 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005551 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5552 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005553 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005554 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005555 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005556 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005557 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5558 << 0 // self-
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005559 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5560 || Opc == BO_LE
5561 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005562 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5563 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5564 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5565 // what is it always going to eval to?
5566 char always_evals_to;
5567 switch(Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005568 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005569 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5570 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005571 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005572 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5573 break;
5574 default:
5575 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5576 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5577 break;
5578 }
5579 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5580 << 1 // array
5581 << always_evals_to);
5582 }
5583 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005584 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005585
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005586 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5587 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5588 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5589 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005590
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005591 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5592 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005593 Expr *literalString = 0;
5594 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005595 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005596 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005597 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005598 literalString = lex;
5599 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005600 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5601 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005602 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005603 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005604 literalString = rex;
5605 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5606 }
5607
5608 if (literalString) {
5609 std::string resultComparison;
5610 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005611 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5612 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5613 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5614 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5615 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5616 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005617 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5618 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005619
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005620 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5621 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5622 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005623 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005624 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005625 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005626
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005627 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5628 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5629 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5630 else {
5631 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5632 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5633 }
5634
5635 lType = lex->getType();
5636 rType = rex->getType();
5637
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005638 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005639 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005640
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005641 if (isRelational) {
5642 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005643 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005644 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005645 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005646 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005647 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005648
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005649 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005650 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005651 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005652
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005653 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005654 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005655 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005656 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005657
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005658 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5659 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005660 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005661 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005662 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005663 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005664 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005665
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005666 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005667 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5668 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005669 if (!isRelational &&
5670 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5671 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5672 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005673 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5674 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005675 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5676 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005677 Diag(Loc,
5678 isSFINAEContext()?
5679 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5680 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005681 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005682
5683 if (isSFINAEContext())
5684 return QualType();
5685
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005686 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005687 return ResultTy;
5688 }
5689 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005690 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5691 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5692 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5693 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5694 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5695 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005696 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005697 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005698 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005699 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005700 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005701 if (T.isNull()) {
5702 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5703 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5704 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005705 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005706 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005707 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005708 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005709 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005710 }
5711
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005712 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5713 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005714 return ResultTy;
5715 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005716 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5717 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5718 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5719 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5720 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5721 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5722 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5723 }
5724 } else if (!isRelational &&
5725 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5726 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5727 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5728 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5729 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5730 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5731 }
5732 } else {
5733 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005734 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005735 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005736 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005737 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005738 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005739 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005740 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005741
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005742 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005743 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005744 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005745 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005746 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5747 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005748 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5749 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005750 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5751 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005752 return ResultTy;
5753 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005754 if (LHSIsNull &&
5755 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5756 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005757 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5758 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005759 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5760 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005761 return ResultTy;
5762 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005763
5764 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005765 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005766 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5767 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005768 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5769 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5770 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5771 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5772 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5773 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5774 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5775 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005776 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005777 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005778 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005779 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005780 if (T.isNull()) {
5781 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005782 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005783 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005784 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005785 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005786 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005787 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005788 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005789 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005790
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005791 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5792 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005793 return ResultTy;
5794 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005795
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005796 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005797 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5798 return ResultTy;
5799 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005800
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005801 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005802 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005803 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5804 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005805
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005806 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005807 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005808 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005809 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005810 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005811 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005812 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005813 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005814 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005815 if (!isRelational
5816 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5817 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005818 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005819 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005820 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005821 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005822 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5823 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5824 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005825 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005826 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005827 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005828 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005829
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005830 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005831 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005832 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5833 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005834 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005835 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005836 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005837 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005838
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005839 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5840 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005841 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005842 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005843 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005844 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005845 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005846 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005847 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005848 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005849 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5850 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005851 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005852 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005853 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005854 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005855 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5856 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005857 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005858 bool isError = false;
5859 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5860 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5861 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005862 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005863 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005864 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005865 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5866 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5867 isError = true;
5868 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005869 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005870
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005871 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005872 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005873 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005874 if (isError)
5875 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005876 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005877
5878 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005879 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005880 else
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005881 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005882 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005883 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005884
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005885 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005886 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5887 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005888 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005889 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005890 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005891 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5892 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005893 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005894 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005895 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005896 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005897}
5898
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005899/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005900/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005901/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5902/// types.
5903QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005904 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005905 bool isRelational) {
5906 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5907 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005908 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005909 if (vType.isNull())
5910 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005911
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005912 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5913 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005914
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005915 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5916 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5917 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005918 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005919 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5920 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5921 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005922 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5923 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5924 << 0 // self-
5925 << 2 // "a constant"
5926 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005927 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005928
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005929 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005930 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5931 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005932 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005933 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005934
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005935 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5936 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5937 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005938 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005939 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005940
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005941 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005942 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005943 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005944 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005945 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005946 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5947
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005948 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005949 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005950 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5951}
5952
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005953inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005954 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005955 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5956 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5957 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5958 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5959
5960 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5961 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005962
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005963 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005964
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005965 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5966 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005967 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005968 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005969}
5970
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005971inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005972 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5973
5974 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5975 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5976 // is a constant.
5977 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005978 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005979 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005980 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5981 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5982 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5983 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5984 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5985 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5986 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5987 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5988 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005989 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5990 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005991 }
5992 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005993
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005994 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5995 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5996 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005997
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005998 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5999 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006000
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006001 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006002 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006003
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006004 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6005 // non-overloadable operands.
6006
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006007 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6008 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006009 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6010 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6011 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006012 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006013
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006014 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6015 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6016 // The result is a bool.
6017 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006018}
6019
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006020/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6021/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6022/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6023///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006024static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006025 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6026 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6027 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006028 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6029 PropExpr->getSuperType() :
6030 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6031
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006032 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006033 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6034 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6035 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6036 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006037 }
6038 }
6039 return false;
6040}
6041
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006042/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6043/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6044static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006045 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006046 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006047 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006048 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6049 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006050 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6051 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006052
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006053 unsigned Diag = 0;
6054 bool NeedType = false;
6055 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006056 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006057 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006058 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6059 NeedType = true;
6060 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006061 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006062 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6063 NeedType = true;
6064 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006065 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006066 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6067 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006068 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6069 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006070 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006071 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6072 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006073 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6074 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006075 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6076 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006077 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006078 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006079 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006080 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006081 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6082 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006083 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006084 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6085 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006086 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6087 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6088 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006089 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6090 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6091 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006092 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6093 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6094 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006095 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006096
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006097 SourceRange Assign;
6098 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6099 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006100 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006101 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006102 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006103 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006104 return true;
6105}
6106
6107
6108
6109// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006110QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6111 SourceLocation Loc,
6112 QualType CompoundType) {
6113 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6114 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006115 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006116
6117 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6118 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006119 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006120 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006121 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006122 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006123 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006124 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006125 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6126 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6127 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006128 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006129 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006130 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006131 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006132
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006133 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6134 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6135 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006136 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006137 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6138 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6139 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006140 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6141 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006142 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006143 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006144 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6145 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6146 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006147 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6148 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006149 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006150 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006151 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006152 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006153 }
6154 } else {
6155 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006156 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006157 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006158
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006159 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006160 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006161 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006162
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006163
6164 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6165 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6166 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6167 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6168 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6169 // check.
6170 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006171 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006172 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6173 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6174 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6175 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6176 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6177 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6178 }
6179
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006180 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6181 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006182 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006183 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6184 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006185 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006186 // operand.
John McCall01cbf2d2010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006187 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6188 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006189}
6190
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006191// C99 6.5.17
6192QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006193 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6194
John McCall73d36182010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006195 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6196 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6197 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6198 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6199 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6200 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6201 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006202
John McCall73d36182010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006203 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6204 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6205 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6206 }
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006207
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006208 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006209}
6210
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006211/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6212/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006213QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006214 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006215 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6216 return Context.DependentTy;
6217
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006218 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6219 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006220
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006221 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6222 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6223 if (!isInc) {
6224 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6225 return QualType();
6226 }
6227 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6228 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6229 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006230 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006231 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6232 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006233
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006234 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006235 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006236 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6237 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6238 << Op->getSourceRange();
6239 return QualType();
6240 }
6241
6242 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006243 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006244 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006245 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6246 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6247 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6248 return QualType();
6249 }
6250
6251 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006252 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006253 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006254 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006255 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006256 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006257 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006258 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006259 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006260 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6261 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6262 return QualType();
6263 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006264 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006265 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6266 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006267 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006268 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6269 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6270 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6271 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006272 } else {
6273 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006274 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006275 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006276 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006277 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006278 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006279 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006280 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006281 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6282 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6283 // operand.
6284 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6285 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006286}
6287
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006288void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6289 bool copyInit = false;
6290 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6291 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6292 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6293 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6294 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6295 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6296 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6297 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6298 }
6299 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6300 }
6301 else
6302 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6303 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6304 if (copyInit) {
6305 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006306 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006307 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6308 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6309 Owned(Arg));
6310 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006311 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006312 }
6313}
6314
6315
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006316/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006317/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006318/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6319/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6320/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6321/// - &(x) => x
6322/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6323/// - &s.xx => s
6324/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6325/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6326/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6327/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006328static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006329 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006330 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006331 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006332 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006333 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6334 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6335 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006336 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006337 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006338 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006339 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006340 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006341 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6342 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006343 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6344 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6345 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6346 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6347 }
6348 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006349 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006350 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6351 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006352
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006353 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006354 case UO_Real:
6355 case UO_Imag:
6356 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006357 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6358 default:
6359 return 0;
6360 }
6361 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006362 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006363 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006364 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006365 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6366 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006367 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006368 default:
6369 return 0;
6370 }
6371}
6372
6373/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006374/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006375/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006376/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006377/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006378/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006379/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006380QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6381 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006382 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006383 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6384 return Context.OverloadTy;
6385
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006386 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6387 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6388 OrigOp = PR.take();
6389
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006390 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6391 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006392
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006393 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6394 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6395 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006396 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006397 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6398 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6399 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6400 }
6401 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6402 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6403 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006404 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006405 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006406
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006407 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006408 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6409 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6410 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6411 if (isSFINAEContext())
6412 return QualType();
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006413 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006414 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006415 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6416 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6417 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6418
6419 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6420 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6421 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6422 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6423 return QualType();
6424 }
6425 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6426 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6427
6428 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6429 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6430 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6431 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6432
6433 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6434 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6435 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6436 << op->getSourceRange();
6437 }
6438
6439 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6440 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6441 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006442 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006443 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006444 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006445 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006446 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6447 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006448 return QualType();
6449 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006450 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006451 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6452 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6453 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006454 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006455 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006456 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006457 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006458 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006459 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006460 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6461 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6462 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6463 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6464 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006465 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6466 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006467 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6468 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006469 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006470 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006471 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6472 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006473 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6474 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCall8e7d6562010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006475 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006476 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006477 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6478 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006479 return QualType();
6480 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006481 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006482 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006483 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006484 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006485 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6486 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006487 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006488 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006489 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6490 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006491 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006492 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6493 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6494 return QualType();
6495 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006496
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006497 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6498 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006499 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006500 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006501 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006502 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006503 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006504
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006505 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6506 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6507 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6508 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6509 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6510 }
6511
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006512 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006513 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6514 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006515 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006516}
6517
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006518/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006519QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006520 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6521 return Context.DependentTy;
6522
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006523 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006524 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6525 QualType Result;
6526
6527 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6528 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6529 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6530 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6531 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6532 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6533 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6534 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6535 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006536 else {
6537 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6538 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6539 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
6540 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006541
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006542 if (Result.isNull()) {
6543 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6544 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6545 return QualType();
6546 }
6547
6548 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006549}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006550
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006551static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006552 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006553 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006554 switch (Kind) {
6555 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006556 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6557 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6558 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6559 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6560 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6561 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6562 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6563 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6564 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6565 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6566 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6567 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6568 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6569 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6570 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6571 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6572 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6573 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6574 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6575 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6576 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6577 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6578 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6579 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6580 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6581 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6582 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6583 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6584 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6585 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6586 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6587 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006588 }
6589 return Opc;
6590}
6591
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006592static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006593 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006594 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006595 switch (Kind) {
6596 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006597 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6598 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6599 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6600 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6601 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6602 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6603 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6604 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6605 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6606 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6607 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006608 }
6609 return Opc;
6610}
6611
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006612/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6613/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6614/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006615ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006616 unsigned Op,
6617 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006618 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006619 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006620 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6621 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6622 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006623
6624 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006625 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006626 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6627 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006628 case BO_PtrMemD:
6629 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006630 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006631 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006632 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006633 case BO_Mul:
6634 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006635 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006636 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006637 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006638 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006639 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6640 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006641 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006642 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6643 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006644 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006645 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6646 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006647 case BO_Shl:
6648 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006649 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6650 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006651 case BO_LE:
6652 case BO_LT:
6653 case BO_GE:
6654 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006655 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006656 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006657 case BO_EQ:
6658 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006659 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006660 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006661 case BO_And:
6662 case BO_Xor:
6663 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006664 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6665 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006666 case BO_LAnd:
6667 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006668 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006669 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006670 case BO_MulAssign:
6671 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006672 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006673 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006674 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6675 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6676 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006677 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006678 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006679 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6680 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6681 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6682 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006683 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006684 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006685 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6686 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6687 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006688 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006689 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006690 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6691 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6692 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006693 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006694 case BO_ShlAssign:
6695 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006696 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6697 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6698 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6699 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006700 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006701 case BO_AndAssign:
6702 case BO_XorAssign:
6703 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006704 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6705 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6706 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6707 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006708 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006709 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006710 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6711 break;
6712 }
6713 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006714 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006715 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006716 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006717 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6718 << ResultTy;
6719 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006720 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006721 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6722 else
6723 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006724 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6725 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006726}
6727
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006728/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6729/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006730static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6731 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006732 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6733 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6734 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006735 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006736 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6737
6738 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6739 return;
6740
6741 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6742 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6743 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006744 return;
6745 }
6746
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006747 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6748 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006749 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006750
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006751 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006752 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006753
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006754 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6755 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6756 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6757 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006758 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006759 return;
6760 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006761
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006762 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006763 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6764 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006765}
6766
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006767/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6768/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6769/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6770/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006771static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006772 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006773 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6774 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6775 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6776 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006777 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006778 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006779 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6780
6781 // Subs are not binary operators.
6782 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6783 return;
6784
6785 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6786 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006787 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6788 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006789 return;
6790
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006791 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006792 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006793 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006794 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6795 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006796 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006797 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006798 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6799 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6800 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6801 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006802 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006803 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006804 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006805 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6806 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006807 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006808 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006809 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6810 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6811 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6812 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006813}
6814
6815/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6816/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6817/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006818static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006819 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006820 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006821 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6822}
6823
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006824// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006825ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006826 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6827 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6828 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006829 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6830 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006831
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006832 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6833 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6834
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006835 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6836}
6837
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006838ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006839 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6840 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006841 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006842 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6843 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianaaf44b22010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006844 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006845 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006846 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6847 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6848 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6849 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6850 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006851 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006852 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006853 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6854 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6855 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006856
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006857 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6858 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006859 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006860 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006861
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006862 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006863 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006864}
6865
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006866ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006867 unsigned OpcIn,
6868 Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006869 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006870
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006871 QualType resultType;
6872 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006873 case UO_PreInc:
6874 case UO_PreDec:
6875 case UO_PostInc:
6876 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006877 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006878 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6879 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6880 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6881 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006882 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006883 case UO_AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006884 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006885 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006886 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006887 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006888 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006889 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006890 case UO_Plus:
6891 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006892 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6893 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006894 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6895 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006896 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6897 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006898 break;
6899 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6900 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6901 break;
6902 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006903 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006904 resultType->isPointerType())
6905 break;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006906 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6907 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6908 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6909 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6910 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006911
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006912 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6913 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006914 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006915 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6916 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006917 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6918 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006919 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6920 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6921 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006922 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006923 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006924 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6925 break;
6926 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6927 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6928 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6929 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6930 } else {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006931 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6932 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006933 }
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006934 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006935 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006936 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006937 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006938 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006939 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6940 break;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006941 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6942 // ok, fallthrough
6943 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6944 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6945 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6946 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6947 } else {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006948 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6949 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006950 }
Douglas Gregordb8c6fd2010-09-20 17:13:33 +00006951
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006952 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006953 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6954 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006955 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006956 case UO_Real:
6957 case UO_Imag:
6958 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006959 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006960 case UO_Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006961 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006962 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006963 }
6964 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006965 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006966
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006967 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006968}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006969
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006970ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006971 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6972 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006973 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman8ed2bac2010-09-05 23:15:52 +00006974 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006975 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6976 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6977 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6978 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006979 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006980 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006981 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6982 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6983 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006984
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006985 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006986 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006987
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006988 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006989}
6990
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006991// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006992ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006993 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6994 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006995}
6996
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006997/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006998ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006999 SourceLocation LabLoc,
7000 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007001 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007002 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007003
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00007004 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
7005 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00007006 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007007 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007008
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007009 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007010 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007011 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7012 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007013}
7014
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007015ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007016Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007017 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007018 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7019 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7020
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007021 bool isFileScope
7022 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007023 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007024 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007025
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007026 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7027 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7028 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007029
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007030 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7031 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7032 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007033
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007034 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7035 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
7036 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
7037 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
7038 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007039
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007040 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007041 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007042 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007043
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007044 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7045 // expressions are not lvalues.
7046
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007047 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007048}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007049
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007050ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007051 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7052 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7053 unsigned NumComponents,
7054 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007055 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007056 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007057 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007058
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007059 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7060 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7061 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007062 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007063 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7064 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7065
7066 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7067 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7068 if (!Dependent
7069 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7070 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7071 << TypeRange))
7072 return ExprError();
7073
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007074 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7075 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007076 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7077 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007078 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007079 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7080 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007081
7082 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7083 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7084 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7085 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7086 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7087 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7088 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7089 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7090 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7091 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7092 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7093 if(!AT)
7094 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7095 << CurrentType);
7096 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7097 } else
7098 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7099
7100 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7101 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7102 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7103 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7104 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7105 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7106 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7107 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7108
7109 // Record this array index.
7110 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7111 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7112 continue;
7113 }
7114
7115 // Offset of a field.
7116 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7117 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7118 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7119 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7120 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7121 continue;
7122 }
7123
7124 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7125 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7126 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7127 return ExprError();
7128
7129 // Look for the designated field.
7130 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7131 if (!RC)
7132 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7133 << CurrentType);
7134 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7135
7136 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7137 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7138 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7139 // (clause 9).
7140 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7141 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7142 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7143 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7144 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7145 << CurrentType))
7146 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7147 }
7148
7149 // Look for the field.
7150 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7151 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7152 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7153 if (!MemberDecl)
7154 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7155 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7156 OC.LocEnd));
7157
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007158 // C99 7.17p3:
7159 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7160 //
7161 // We diagnose this as an error.
7162 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7163 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7164 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7165 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7166 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7167 return ExprError();
7168 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007169
7170 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7171 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7172 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7173 do {
7174 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7175 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7176 }
7177
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007178 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7179 // the base class indirections.
7180 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7181 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007182 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007183 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7184 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7185 B != BEnd; ++B)
7186 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7187 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007188
7189 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007190 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7191 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7192 unsigned n = Path.size();
7193 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7194 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7195 } else {
7196 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7197 }
7198 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7199 }
7200
7201 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7202 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7203 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7204}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007205
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007206ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007207 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7208 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7209 ParsedType argty,
7210 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7211 unsigned NumComponents,
7212 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7213
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007214 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7215 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7216 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7217 return ExprError();
7218
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007219 if (!ArgTInfo)
7220 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7221
7222 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7223 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007224}
7225
7226
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007227ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007228 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7229 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007230 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7231 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7232 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7233 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007234
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007235 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007236
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007237 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7238}
7239
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007240ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007241Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7242 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7243 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7244 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007245 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7246 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7247 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7248 return ExprError();
7249 }
7250
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007251 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007252 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007253}
7254
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007255
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007256ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007257 Expr *CondExpr,
7258 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7259 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007260 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7261
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007262 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007263 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007264 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007265 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007266 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007267 } else {
7268 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7269 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7270 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7271 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007272 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7273 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7274 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007275
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007276 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7277 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007278 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7279 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007280 }
7281
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007282 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007283 resType, RPLoc,
7284 resType->isDependentType(),
7285 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007286}
7287
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007288//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7289// Clang Extensions.
7290//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7291
7292/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007293void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007294 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7295 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7296 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007297 if (BlockScope)
7298 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7299 else
7300 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007301}
7302
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007303void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007304 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007305 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007306
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007307 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007308 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007309 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007310
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007311 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007312 QualType RetTy;
7313 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007314 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007315 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007316 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007317 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7318 } else {
7319 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007320 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007321 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007322
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007323 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007324
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007325 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7326 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7327 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007328 return;
7329 }
7330
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007331 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7332 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7333 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7334 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7335 return;
7336 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007337
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007338 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007339 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7340 // ^ * { ... }
7341 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007342 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7343 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007344
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007345 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007346 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007347 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7348 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7349 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7350 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007351 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7352 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7353 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7354 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7355 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007356 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007357 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007358
7359 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7360 // ^ fntype { ... }
7361 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7362 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7363 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7364 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7365 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7366 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7367 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007368 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007369 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007370 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007371
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007372 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7373 if (!Params.empty())
7374 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007375
7376 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007377 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007378
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007379 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007380 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7381 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7382 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7383 }
7384
7385 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7386 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007387 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007388 return;
7389
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007390 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7391 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7392
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007393 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007394 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7395 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7396
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007397 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007398 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7399 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7400 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7401
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007402 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007403 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007404 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007405}
7406
7407/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7408/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7409void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007410 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007411 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007412 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007413 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007414}
7415
7416/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7417/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007418ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007419 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007420 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7421 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7422 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007423
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007424 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007425
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007426 PopDeclContext();
7427
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007428 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007429 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7430 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007431
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007432 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007433 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007434
7435 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7436 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7437 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7438
7439 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7440 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7441
7442 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7443 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7444 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7445 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7446
7447 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7448 // preserve its sugar structure.
7449 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7450 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7451 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7452
7453 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7454 } else {
7455 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7456 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7457 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7458 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7459 FPT->isVariadic(),
7460 /*quals*/ 0,
7461 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7462 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7463 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7464 FPT->exception_begin(),
7465 Ext);
7466 }
7467
7468 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7469 } else {
7470 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7471 false, false, 0, 0,
7472 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7473 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007474
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007475 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007476 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7477 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007478 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007479
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007480 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007481 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007482 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007483
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007484 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007485
7486 bool Good = true;
7487 // Check goto/label use.
7488 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7489 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7490 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7491
7492 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7493 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007494 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7495 if (!L->isUsed())
7496 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007497 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007498 }
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007499
7500 // Emit error.
7501 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7502 Good = false;
7503 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007504 if (!Good) {
7505 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007506 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007507 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007508
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007509 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7510 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7511
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007512 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007513 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7514 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007515 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007516
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007517 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007518 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007519}
7520
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007521ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007522 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007523 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007524 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7525 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007526 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007527}
7528
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007529ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007530 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007531 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007532 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007533
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007534 // Get the va_list type
7535 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007536 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7537 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7538 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7539 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007540 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007541 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7542 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7543 } else {
7544 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7545 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007546 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007547 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007548 return ExprError();
7549 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007550
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007551 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7552 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007553 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7554 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007555 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007556 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007557
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007558 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007559 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007560
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007561 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7562 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007563}
7564
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007565ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007566 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7567 // pointers on the target.
7568 QualType Ty;
7569 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7570 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7571 else
7572 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7573
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007574 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007575}
7576
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007577static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007578 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007579 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7580 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007581
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007582 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7583 if (!PT)
7584 return;
7585
7586 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7587 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7588 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7589 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7590 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7591 return;
7592 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007593
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007594 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7595 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7596 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7597 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007598
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007599 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007600}
7601
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007602bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7603 SourceLocation Loc,
7604 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007605 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7606 bool *Complained) {
7607 if (Complained)
7608 *Complained = false;
7609
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007610 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7611 bool isInvalid = false;
7612 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007613 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007614
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007615 switch (ConvTy) {
7616 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7617 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007618 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007619 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7620 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007621 case IntToPointer:
7622 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7623 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007624 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007625 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007626 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7627 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007628 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7629 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7630 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007631 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7632 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7633 break;
7634 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007635 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7636 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7637 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7638 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7639 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7640 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7641 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7642 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7643 // C++ semantics.
7644 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7645 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7646 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007647 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7648 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007649 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007650 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007651 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007652 case IntToBlockPointer:
7653 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7654 break;
7655 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007656 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007657 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007658 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007659 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007660 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7661 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7662 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007663 case IncompatibleVectors:
7664 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7665 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007666 case Incompatible:
7667 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7668 isInvalid = true;
7669 break;
7670 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007671
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007672 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7673 switch (Action) {
7674 case AA_Assigning:
7675 case AA_Initializing:
7676 // The destination type comes first.
7677 FirstType = DstType;
7678 SecondType = SrcType;
7679 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007680
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007681 case AA_Returning:
7682 case AA_Passing:
7683 case AA_Converting:
7684 case AA_Sending:
7685 case AA_Casting:
7686 // The source type comes first.
7687 FirstType = SrcType;
7688 SecondType = DstType;
7689 break;
7690 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007691
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007692 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007693 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007694 if (Complained)
7695 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007696 return isInvalid;
7697}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007698
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007699bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007700 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7701 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7702 if (Result)
7703 *Result = ICEResult;
7704 return false;
7705 }
7706
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007707 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7708
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007709 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007710 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7711 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7712
7713 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7714 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7715 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7716 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7717 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7718 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7719 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007720
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007721 return true;
7722 }
7723
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007724 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7725 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007726
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007727 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7728 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7729 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007730
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007731 if (Result)
7732 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7733 return false;
7734}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007735
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007736void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007737Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007738 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7739 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007740}
7741
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007742void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007743Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7744 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7745 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7746 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007747
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007748 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7749 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7750 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7751 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7752 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007753 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007754 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7755 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7756 I != IEnd; ++I)
7757 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7758 }
7759
7760 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7761 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7762 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7763 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7764 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7765 I != IEnd; ++I)
7766 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7767 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007768 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007769
7770 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7771 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7772 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7773 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007774 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007775 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7776 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7777 ExprTemporaries.end());
7778
7779 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7780 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007781}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007782
7783/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7784///
7785/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7786/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7787/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7788/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7789///
7790/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7791///
7792/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7793void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7794 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007795
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007796 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007797 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007798
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007799 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7800 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7801 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7802 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007803 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007804 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007805 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007806 return;
7807 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007808
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007809 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7810 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007811
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007812 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7813 // an instantiation.
7814 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7815 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007816
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007817 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007818 case Unevaluated:
7819 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7820 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007821
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007822 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7823 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7824 // "used"; handle this below.
7825 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007826
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007827 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7828 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7829 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7830 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007831 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007832 return;
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007833
7834 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7835 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7836 // containing expression is used.
7837 return;
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007838 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007839
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007840 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007841 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007842 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007843 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007844 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7845 return;
7846 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7847 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007848 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007849 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007850 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007851 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7852 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007853
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007854 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007855 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007856 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007857 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007858 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7859 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007860 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7861 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7862 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007863 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007864 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007865 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7866 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007867 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007868 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007869 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007870 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007871 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007872 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7873 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7874 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7875 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7876 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007877 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007878 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007879 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007880 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007881 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7882 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7883 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007884 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007885 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007886 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7887 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007888
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007889 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7890 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7891 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7892 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7893 Loc));
7894 else
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007895 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007896 }
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007897 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7898 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7899 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greif34ecff22010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007900 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007901 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7902 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007903
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007904 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdfffabd2010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007905
7906 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7907 if (CurContext != Function)
7908 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007909
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007910 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007911 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007912
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007913 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007914 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007915 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007916 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7917 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7918 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7919 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7920 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7921 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007922 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007923 }
7924 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007925
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007926 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007927
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007928 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007929 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007930 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007931}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007932
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007933namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007934 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007935 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007936 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007937 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7938 Sema &S;
7939 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007940
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007941 public:
7942 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007943
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007944 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007945
7946 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7947 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007948 };
7949}
7950
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007951bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7952 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007953 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7954 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7955 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007956
7957 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007958}
7959
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007960bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007961 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7962 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7963 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007964 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7965 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007966 }
7967
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007968 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007969}
7970
7971void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7972 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007973 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007974}
7975
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007976namespace {
7977 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
7978 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7979 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
7980 Sema &S;
7981
7982 public:
7983 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
7984
7985 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
7986
7987 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
7988 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7989 }
7990
7991 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
7992 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007993 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007994 }
7995
7996 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
7997 if (E->getConstructor())
7998 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
7999 if (E->getOperatorNew())
8000 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
8001 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8002 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008003 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008004 }
8005
8006 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
8007 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8008 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00008009 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8010 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8011 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8012 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8013 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8014 }
8015
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008016 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008017 }
8018
8019 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8020 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008021 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008022 }
8023
8024 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8025 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8026 }
Douglas Gregorf0873f42010-10-19 17:17:35 +00008027
8028 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
8029 Visit(E->getExpr());
8030 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008031 };
8032}
8033
8034/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8035/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8036void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8037 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8038}
8039
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008040/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8041/// of the program being compiled.
8042///
8043/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008044/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008045/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8046/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8047/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8048/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008049/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008050/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008051///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008052/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8053/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8054/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8055/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008056bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008057 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8058 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8059 case Unevaluated:
8060 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8061 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008062
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008063 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008064 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008065 Diag(Loc, PD);
8066 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008067
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008068 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8069 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8070 break;
8071 }
8072
8073 return false;
8074}
8075
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008076bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8077 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8078 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8079 return false;
8080
8081 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8082 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8083 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8084 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008085
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008086 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008087 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008088 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8089 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008090 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008091 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8092 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8093 return true;
8094
8095 return false;
8096}
8097
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008098// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8099// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8100void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8101 SourceLocation Loc;
8102
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008103 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8104
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008105 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8106 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008107 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008108 return;
8109
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008110 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8111 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8112 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8113 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8114
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008115 // self = [<foo> init...]
8116 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8117 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8118 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8119
8120 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8121 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8122 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8123 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8124 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008125
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008126 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8127 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8128 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8129 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8130 return;
8131
8132 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8133 } else {
8134 // Not an assignment.
8135 return;
8136 }
8137
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008138 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008139 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008140
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008141 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008142 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008143 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008144 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8145 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8146 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008147}
8148
8149bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8150 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8151
8152 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008153 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008154
8155 QualType T = E->getType();
8156
8157 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8158 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8159 return true;
8160 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8161 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8162 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8163 return true;
8164 }
8165 }
8166
8167 return false;
8168}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008169
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008170ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8171 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008172 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008173 return ExprError();
8174
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008175 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008176 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008177
8178 return Owned(Sub);
8179}
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008180
8181/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8182/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8183ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8184 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8185 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8186
8187 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8188 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8189 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8190 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8191 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8192 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8193 Specialization->getAccess());
8194 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8195 if (!E) return ExprError();
8196 return Owned(E);
8197 }
8198
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008199 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008200 return ExprError();
8201 }
8202
8203 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8204 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8205
8206 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8207 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8208 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8209 return ExprError();
8210}